jtag/drivers/openjtag: Add support for Cypress CY7C65215
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a server.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Server Configuration
1998 @chapter Server Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2407 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2408 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2409
2410 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2411 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX.
2412
2413 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2414 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2415 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2416
2417 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2418 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2419 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2420 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2421 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2422 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2423
2424 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2425 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2426 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2427 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2428
2429 @itemize @minus
2430 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2431 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2432 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2433 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2434 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2435 switching data and direction as necessary
2436 @end itemize
2437
2438 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2439 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2440
2441 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2442 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2443 default values are used.
2444 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2445 @example
2446 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2447 @end example
2448 @end deffn
2449
2450 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2451 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2452 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2453 during device selection.
2454 @end deffn
2455
2456 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2457 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2458 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2459 is connected to the host.
2460 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2461 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2462 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2466 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2467 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2468 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2469 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2470 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2471
2472 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2476 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2477 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2478 @end deffn
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2481 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2482 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2483 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2484 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2485 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2486 and initially asserted reset signals.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2490 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2491 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2492 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2493 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2494 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2495 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2496 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2497 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2498 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2499 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2500
2501 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2502 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2503 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2504 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2505 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2506 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2507
2508 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2509 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2510 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2511 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2512 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2513 are always driven by the FTDI.
2514
2515 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2516 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2517 @var{name}.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2521 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2522 @itemize @minus
2523 @item @option{0}, drive low
2524 @item @option{1}, drive high
2525 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2526 @end itemize
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2530 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2534 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2535
2536 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2537 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2538 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2539 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2540 @itemize @minus
2541 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2542 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2543 @end itemize
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2547 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2548
2549 @end deffn
2550
2551 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2552 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2553 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2554 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2555
2556 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2557 processors which are being simulated.
2558
2559 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2560 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2561 sockets instead of TCP.
2562 @end deffn
2563
2564 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2565 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2566 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2570 something like:
2571
2572 @example
2573 interface remote_bitbang
2574 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2575 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2576 @end example
2577
2578 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2579 named mysocket:
2580
2581 @example
2582 interface remote_bitbang
2583 remote_bitbang_port 0
2584 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2585 @end example
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2589 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2590 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2591 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2592
2593 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2594 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2595 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2596 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2597 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2601 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2602 default values are used.
2603 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2604 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2605 @example
2606 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2607 @end example
2608 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2609 @example
2610 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2611 @end example
2612 @end deffn
2613
2614 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2615 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2616 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2617 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2618 target board.
2619
2620 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2621 @example
2622 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2623 reset_config srst_only
2624 @end example
2625 @end deffn
2626
2627 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2628 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2629 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2630 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2634 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2635 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2641 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2642 This has one driver-specific command:
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2645 Display either the address of the I/O port
2646 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2647 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2648 This is a write-once setting.
2649 @end deffn
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2653 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2654 transports.
2655
2656 @quotation Compatibility Note
2657 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2658 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2659 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2660 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2661 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2662 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2663 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2664 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2665 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2666 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2667 @end quotation
2668
2669 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2670 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2671 states.
2672 @end deffn
2673 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2674 Display free device internal memory.
2675 @end deffn
2676 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2677 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2678 command version.
2679 @end deffn
2680 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2681 Display the device configuration.
2682 @end deffn
2683 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2684 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2685 power state.
2686 @end deffn
2687 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2688 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2689 @end deffn
2690 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2691 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2692 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2693 IP configuration.
2694 @end deffn
2695 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2696 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2697 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2698 @end deffn
2699 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2700 Reset the current configuration.
2701 @end deffn
2702 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2703 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2704 @end deffn
2705 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2706 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2707 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2708 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2709 instead.
2710
2711 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2712 @end deffn
2713 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2714 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2715 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2716
2717 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2718 @end deffn
2719 @end deffn
2720
2721 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2722 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2723 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2724 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2725 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2726
2727 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2728 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2729 This is a write-once setting.
2730 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2731
2732 @itemize @minus
2733 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2734 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2735 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2736 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2737 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2738 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2739 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2740 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2741 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2742 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2743 some versions of
2744 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2745 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2746 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2747 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2748 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2749 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2750 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2751 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2752 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2753 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2754 @end itemize
2755 @end deffn
2756
2757 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2758 Display either the address of the I/O port
2759 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2760 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2761 This is a write-once setting.
2762
2763 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2764 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2765 you may encounter a problem.
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2769 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2770 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2771 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2772 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2773 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2774
2775 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2776 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2777 @quotation Tip
2778 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2779 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2780 @example
2781 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2782 > adapter_khz 500
2783 @end example
2784 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2785 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2786 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2787 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2788 large set of samples.
2789 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2790 @example
2791 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2792 @end example
2793 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2794 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2795
2796 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2797 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2798 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2799 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2800 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2801 @end quotation
2802 @end deffn
2803
2804 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2805 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2806 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2807 @end deffn
2808
2809 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2810 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2811
2812 @example
2813 interface parport
2814 parport_port 0x278
2815 parport_cable wiggler
2816 @end example
2817 @end deffn
2818
2819 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2820 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2821 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2822 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @end deffn
2825
2826 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2827 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2828 @end deffn
2829
2830 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2831 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2832 @end deffn
2833
2834 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2835 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2836
2837 @quotation Note
2838 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2839 which are not currently documented here.
2840 @end quotation
2841 @end deffn
2842
2843 @anchor{hla_interface}
2844 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2845 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2846 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2847 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2848
2849 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2850 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2851 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2852 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2853 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2854
2855 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2856 Currently Not Supported.
2857 @end deffn
2858
2859 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2860 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2861 @end deffn
2862
2863 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2864 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2865 @end deffn
2866
2867 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2868 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2869 @end deffn
2870
2871 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2872 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2873 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @end deffn
2876
2877 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2878 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2882 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2883 @end deffn
2884
2885 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2886 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2887 @end deffn
2888
2889 @quotation Note
2890 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2891 which are not currently documented here.
2892 @end quotation
2893
2894 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2895 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2896 No arguments: print status.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2900 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2901 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2902
2903 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2904 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2905 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2906 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2907 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2908 configuration on exit.
2909
2910 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2911 pinout.
2912
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
2916 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
2917 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2918
2919 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
2920 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
2921 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
2922
2923 @itemize @minus
2924 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
2925 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
2926 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
2927 @end itemize
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
2931 The USB device description string of the adapter.
2932 This value is only used with the standard variant.
2933 @end deffn
2934 @end deffn
2935
2936 @section Transport Configuration
2937 @cindex Transport
2938 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2939 and the debug adapter you are using,
2940 several transports may be available to
2941 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2942 @deffn Command {transport list}
2943 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2944 version of OpenOCD.
2945 @end deffn
2946
2947 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2948 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2949
2950 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2951 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2952 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2953 adapter's driver).
2954
2955 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2956 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2957 supported by the debug adapter.
2958
2959 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2960 transport, if any.
2961 @end deffn
2962
2963 @subsection JTAG Transport
2964 @cindex JTAG
2965 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
2966 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
2967 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
2968 each of which must be explicitly declared.
2969 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
2970 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2971
2972 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2973 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2974 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2975 hla_jtag}.
2976
2977 @subsection SWD Transport
2978 @cindex SWD
2979 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
2980 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
2981 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
2982 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
2983 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
2984 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2985 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
2986
2987 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2988 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2989 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2990 hla_swd}.
2991
2992 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
2993 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
2994 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
2995 expected to change.
2996 @end deffn
2997 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
2998 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
2999 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3000 No parameters: displays current settings.
3001 @end deffn
3002
3003 @subsection SPI Transport
3004 @cindex SPI
3005 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3006 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3007 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3008 solution for flash programming.
3009
3010 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3011 @section JTAG Speed
3012 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3013 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3014 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3015 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3016 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3017 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3018 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3019 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3020 power management software that may be active.
3021
3022 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3023 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3024 target event handler.
3025 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3026 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3027 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3028 sets up those clocks).
3029 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3030 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3031 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3032 in the target config file.
3033 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3034 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3035 config file instead.
3036 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3037 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3038 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3039
3040 @example
3041 jtag_rclk 3000
3042 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3043 @end example
3044
3045 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3046 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3047 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3048 may not be the fastest solution.
3049
3050 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3051 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3052 which support adaptive clocking.
3053
3054 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3055 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3056 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3057 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3058 than the speed specified.
3059
3060 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3061 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3062 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3063 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3064
3065 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3066 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3067 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3068 JTAG clocking after setup.
3069 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3070 If the interface device can not
3071 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3072 @end deffn
3073
3074 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3075 @cindex adaptive clocking
3076 @cindex RTCK
3077 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3078 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3079 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3080 @example
3081 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3082 jtag_rclk 3000
3083 @end example
3084 @end defun
3085
3086 @node Reset Configuration
3087 @chapter Reset Configuration
3088 @cindex Reset Configuration
3089
3090 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3091 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3092 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3093 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3094 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3095 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3096 Please see the various board files for examples.
3097
3098 @quotation Note
3099 To maintainers and integrators:
3100 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3101 Normally the board configuration file
3102 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3103 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3104
3105 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3106 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3107 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3108 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3109 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3110 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3111 @end quotation
3112
3113 @section Types of Reset
3114
3115 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3116 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3117 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3118
3119 @itemize @bullet
3120 @item
3121 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3122 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3123 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3124 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3125 @item
3126 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3127 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3128 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3129 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3130 @item
3131 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3132 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3133 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3134 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3135 @item
3136 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3137 several other types of reset.
3138 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3139 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3140 There may be individual module resets.
3141 @end itemize
3142
3143 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3144 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3145 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3146 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3147 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3148 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3149 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3150 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3151 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3152
3153 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3154 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3155
3156 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3157 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3158 common issues are:
3159
3160 @itemize @bullet
3161
3162 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3163 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3164 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3165 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3166 when either of those signals is not connected.
3167 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3168 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3169 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3170 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3171
3172 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3173 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3174 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3175 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3176
3177 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3178 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3179 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3180 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3181 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3182 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3183 hardware debouncing.
3184 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3185 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3186
3187 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3188 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3189 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3190 to use push/pull output drivers.
3191 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3192 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3193 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3194 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3195
3196 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3197 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3198 issues (not limited to errata).
3199 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3200 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3201 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3202 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3203 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3204 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3205 @end itemize
3206
3207 There can also be other issues.
3208 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3209 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3210 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3211 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3212 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3213 Agreement (NDA).
3214
3215 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3216 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3217 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3218
3219 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3220 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3221
3222 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3223
3224 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3225 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3226 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3227 allowing it to be deasserted.
3228 @end deffn
3229
3230 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3231 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3232 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3233 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3234 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3235 @end deffn
3236
3237 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3238 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3239 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3240 allowing it to be deasserted.
3241 @end deffn
3242
3243 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3244 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3245 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3246 @end deffn
3247
3248 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3249 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3250 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3251 configuration scripts.
3252
3253 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3254 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3255 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3256 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3257 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3258 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3259 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3260 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3261
3262 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3263 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3264 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3265 -- may be specified at a time.
3266 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3267 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3268 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3269 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3270 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3271
3272 @itemize
3273 @item
3274 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3275 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3276 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3277 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3278 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3279
3280 @quotation Tip
3281 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3282 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3283 @end quotation
3284
3285 @item
3286 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3287 signal implementations.
3288 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3289 indicating everything behaves normally.
3290 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3291 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3292 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3293 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3294 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3295 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3296 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3297
3298 @item
3299 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3300 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3301 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3302 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3303 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3304 while SRST is asserted.
3305 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3306 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3307
3308 @item
3309 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3310 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3311 is required to use this option.
3312 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3313 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3314 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3315 be asserted before any target connection.
3316 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3317 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3318 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3319 @end itemize
3320
3321 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3322 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3323 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3324 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3325 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3326
3327 @itemize
3328 @item
3329 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3330 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3331 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3332 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3333
3334 @item
3335 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3336 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3337 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3338 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3339 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3340 @end itemize
3341 @end deffn
3342
3343 @section Custom Reset Handling
3344 @cindex events
3345
3346 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3347 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3348 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3349 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3350 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3351 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3352
3353 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3354 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3355 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3356 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3357 want to reset everything at once.
3358
3359 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3360 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3361 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3362 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3363 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3364 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3365 needs special attention.
3366
3367 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3368 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3369 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3370 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3371 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3372 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3373 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3374 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3375
3376 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3377 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3378 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3379 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3380 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3381
3382 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3383 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3384 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3385 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3386 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3387 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3388 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3389 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3390 or potentially some other value.
3391
3392 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3393 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3394 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3395 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3396 (or their associated targets)
3397 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3398
3399 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3400 they return.
3401 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3402 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3403 @end deffn
3404
3405 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3406 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3407 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3408 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3409 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3410 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3411 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3412 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3413 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3414 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3415 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3416 @end deffn
3417
3418 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3419 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3420 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3421 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3422 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3423 @end deffn
3424
3425
3426 @node TAP Declaration
3427 @chapter TAP Declaration
3428 @cindex TAP declaration
3429 @cindex TAP configuration
3430
3431 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3432 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3433
3434 @itemize @bullet
3435 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3436 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3437 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3438 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3439 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3440 start running that code.
3441 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3442 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3443 and missing connections.
3444 @end itemize
3445
3446 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3447 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3448 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3449 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3450 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3451
3452 @section Scan Chains
3453 @cindex scan chain
3454
3455 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3456 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3457 They also need to be added to
3458 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3459 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3460 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3461 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3462 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3463 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3464 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3465 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3466
3467 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3468 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3469 command, presented in the next chapter.
3470 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3471 debugging targets.)
3472 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3473
3474 @verbatim
3475 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3476 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3477 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3478 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3479 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3480 @end verbatim
3481
3482 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3483 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3484 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3485 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3486 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3487 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3488 until they are told to do so.
3489
3490 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3491 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3492 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3493 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3494
3495 @example
3496 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3497 @end example
3498
3499 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3500 by a given chip.
3501 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3502 and so forth.
3503 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3504 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3505 both inside a single chip and between them.
3506 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3507
3508 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3509 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3510 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3511 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3512 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3513 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3514 includes commands something like this:
3515
3516 @example
3517 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3518 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3519 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3520 @end example
3521
3522 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3523 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3524 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3525
3526 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3527 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3528 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3529 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3530 @example
3531 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3532 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3533 @}
3534 @end example
3535 @end deffn
3536
3537 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3538 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3539 and their status.
3540 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3541 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3542 but systems with a JTAG router can
3543 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3544 @end deffn
3545
3546 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3547 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3548
3549 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3550 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3551
3552 @section TAP Names
3553 @cindex dotted name
3554
3555 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3556 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3557 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3558 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3559 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3560 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3561 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3562 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3563
3564 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3565 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3566 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3567
3568 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3569
3570 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3571 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3572 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3573 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3574
3575 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3576 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3577 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3578 overridable.
3579
3580 @cindex TAP naming convention
3581 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3582 and should follow this convention:
3583
3584 @itemize @bullet
3585 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3586 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3587 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3588 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3589 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3590 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3591 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3592 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3593 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3594 with a single TAP;
3595 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3596 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3597 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3598 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3599 @end itemize
3600
3601 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3602
3603 @itemize @bullet
3604 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3605 @*The length in bits of the
3606 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3607 @end itemize
3608
3609 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3610
3611 @itemize @bullet
3612 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3613 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3614 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3615 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3616 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3617 (the TAP is linked in).
3618 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3619 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3620 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3621 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3622 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3623 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3624 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3625 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3626 values that were found but not included in the list.
3627
3628 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3629 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3630 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3631 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3632 hardware to find these values.
3633 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3634 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3635 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3636 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3637 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3638 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3639 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3640 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3641 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3642 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3643 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3644 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3645 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3646 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3647 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3648 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3649 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3650 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3651 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3652 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3653 @end itemize
3654 @end deffn
3655
3656 @section Other TAP commands
3657
3658 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3659 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3660 At this writing this TAP attribute
3661 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3662 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3663 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3664 See the next section for information about the available events.
3665
3666 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3667 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3668 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3669 @end deffn
3670
3671 @section TAP Events
3672 @cindex events
3673 @cindex TAP events
3674
3675 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3676 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3677 The other applies to debugger targets,
3678 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3679
3680 The TAP events currently defined are:
3681
3682 @itemize @bullet
3683 @item @b{post-reset}
3684 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3685 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3686 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3687 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3688 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3689
3690 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3691 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3692 of any particular target.
3693 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3694 @item @b{setup}
3695 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3696 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3697 @item @b{tap-disable}
3698 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3699 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3700 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3701 @item @b{tap-enable}
3702 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3703 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3704 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3705 @end itemize
3706
3707 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3708 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3709 contents to be accurate), you might:
3710
3711 @example
3712 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3713 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3714 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3715 @}
3716 @end example
3717
3718
3719 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3720 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3721 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3722 @cindex jrc
3723
3724 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3725 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3726 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3727 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3728 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3729
3730 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3731 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3732 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3733 be visible.
3734 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3735 ignores, such as:
3736
3737 @itemize
3738 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3739 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3740 TAPs receive new instructions.
3741 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3742 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3743 @end itemize
3744
3745 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3746 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3747 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3748 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3749
3750 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3751 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3752
3753 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3754 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3755 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3756 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3757 should define TAP event handlers using
3758 code that looks something like this:
3759
3760 @example
3761 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3762 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3763 @}
3764 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3765 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3766 @}
3767 @end example
3768
3769 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3770
3771 @example
3772 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3773 @end example
3774
3775 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3776 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3777 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3778 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3779
3780 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3781 If necessary, disables the tap
3782 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3783 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3784 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3785 and "0" if it is disabled.
3786 @end deffn
3787
3788 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3789 If necessary, enables the tap
3790 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3791 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3792 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3793 and "0" if it is disabled.
3794 @end deffn
3795
3796 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3797 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3798 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3799 and "0" if it is disabled.
3800
3801 @quotation Note
3802 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3803 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3804 @end quotation
3805 @end deffn
3806
3807 @anchor{autoprobing}
3808 @section Autoprobing
3809 @cindex autoprobe
3810 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3811
3812 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3813 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3814 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3815 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3816
3817 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3818 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3819 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3820 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3821 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3822 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3823 right when they come out of reset).
3824
3825 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3826
3827 @example
3828 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3829 reset_config trst_and_srst
3830 jtag_rclk 8
3831 @end example
3832
3833 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3834 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3835
3836 @enumerate
3837 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3838 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3839 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3840 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3841 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3842 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3843 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3844 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3845 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3846 that is discovered.
3847 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3848 register, it will report it.
3849 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3850 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3851 @end enumerate
3852
3853 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3854 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3855 that's a bit more complex:
3856
3857 @example
3858 clock speed 8 kHz
3859 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3860 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3861 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3862 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3863 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3864 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3865 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3866 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3867 @end example
3868
3869 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3870 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3871 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3872 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3873 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3874 and so forth.
3875
3876 @node CPU Configuration
3877 @chapter CPU Configuration
3878 @cindex GDB target
3879
3880 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3881 You can also access these targets without GDB
3882 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3883 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3884 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3885 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3886
3887 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3888 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3889
3890 @section Target List
3891 @cindex target, current
3892 @cindex target, list
3893
3894 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3895 where each member has a name.
3896 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3897 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3898 (plural!) command.
3899 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3900 look like with more than one:
3901 @verbatim
3902 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3903 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3904 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3905 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3906 @end verbatim
3907
3908 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3909 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3910 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3911 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3912 space seen by that current target.
3913 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3914 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3915 are examples; and there are many more.
3916
3917 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3918
3919 @deffn Command {target current}
3920 Returns the name of the current target.
3921 @end deffn
3922
3923 @deffn Command {target names}
3924 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3925 @example
3926 foreach t [target names] @{
3927 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3928 @}
3929 @end example
3930 @end deffn
3931
3932 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3933 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3934
3935 @deffn Command targets [name]
3936 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3937 command names are singular.}
3938
3939 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3940 targets in a user friendly form.
3941
3942 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3943 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3944 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3945 @end deffn
3946
3947 @section Target CPU Types
3948 @cindex target type
3949 @cindex CPU type
3950
3951 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3952 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3953 when calling @command{target create}.
3954 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3955 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3956 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3957 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3958 what core-specific commands may be available
3959 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3960 and more.
3961
3962 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3963 since there's a command to list them.
3964
3965 @anchor{targettypes}
3966 @deffn Command {target types}
3967 Lists all supported target types.
3968 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
3969
3970 @itemize @bullet
3971 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
3972 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3973 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3974 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3975 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
3976 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
3977 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3978 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
3979 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
3980 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
3981 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
3982 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
3983 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
3984 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
3985 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
3986 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
3987 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
3988 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
3989 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
3990 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
3991 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
3992 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
3993 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
3994 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
3995 @itemize @minus
3996 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
3997 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
3998 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
3999 @end itemize
4000 And two debug interfaces cores:
4001 @itemize @minus
4002 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4003 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4004 @end itemize
4005 @end itemize
4006 @end deffn
4007
4008 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4009 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4010 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4011 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4012 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4013 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4014 reflect design generations;
4015 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
4016 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4017
4018 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4019 @section Target Configuration
4020
4021 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4022 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4023 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4024 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4025 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4026
4027 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4028 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4029 optional parts.
4030 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4031 command, created as part of target creation.
4032
4033 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4034 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4035 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4036 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4037 to be much more board-specific.
4038 The key steps you use might look something like this
4039
4040 @example
4041 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4042 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4043 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4044 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4045 @end example
4046
4047 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4048 on-chip SRAM.
4049 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4050 writes to target memory;
4051 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4052 GDB memory checksumming;
4053 and more.
4054
4055 @quotation Warning
4056 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4057 inaccessible when application code
4058 (such as an operating system)
4059 enables or disables the MMU.
4060 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4061 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4062 easy access to other addresses needed.
4063 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4064 @end quotation
4065
4066 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4067 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4068 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4069 controllers.
4070 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4071 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4072 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4073
4074 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4075 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4076 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4077 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4078 purposes including additional configuration.
4079
4080 @itemize @bullet
4081 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4082 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4083 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4084 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4085
4086 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4087 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4088 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4089 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4090 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4091 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4092 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4093
4094 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4095 @end itemize
4096 @end deffn
4097
4098 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4099 The options accepted by this command may also be
4100 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4101 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4102 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4103
4104 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4105 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4106 and changing its endianness.
4107
4108 @itemize @bullet
4109
4110 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4111 used to access this target.
4112
4113 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4114 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4115
4116 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4117 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4118 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4119 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4120 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4121 same event name assigns only one handler.
4122
4123 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4124 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4125 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4126 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4127 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4128 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4129 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4130
4131 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4132 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4133 or virtual address is being used.
4134
4135 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4136 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4137
4138 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4139 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4140 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4141 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4142 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4143
4144 @anchor{rtostype}
4145 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4146 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4147 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}|
4148 @option{uCOS-III}
4149 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4150
4151 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4152 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4153 access the target for debugging.
4154
4155 @end itemize
4156 @end deffn
4157
4158 @section Other $target_name Commands
4159 @cindex object command
4160
4161 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4162 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4163
4164 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4165 Once a button is created a button
4166 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4167 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4168 configure it like this:
4169
4170 @example
4171 # Create
4172 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4173 # Modify
4174 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4175 # Query
4176 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4177 # Report
4178 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4179 @end example
4180
4181 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4182 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4183
4184 @example
4185 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4186 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4187 @end example
4188
4189 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4190
4191 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4192 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4193 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4194 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4195 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4196 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4197 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4198 They are not otherwise documented here.
4199 @end deffn
4200
4201 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4202 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4203 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4204 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4205 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4206 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4207 the target side uses raw memory.
4208
4209 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4210 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4211 The script orientation comes from working with data
4212 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4213 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4214 and neither store nor return those values.
4215
4216 @itemize
4217 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4218 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4219 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4220 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4221 @end itemize
4222 @end deffn
4223
4224 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4225 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4226 @command{$target_name configure}
4227 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4228 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4229 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4230 There are a few special cases:
4231
4232 @itemize @bullet
4233 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4234 event named @var{event_name}.
4235 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4236 two parameters.
4237 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4238 This is a special case because this is set using
4239 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4240 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4241 @end itemize
4242
4243 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4244 all the targets you might use something like this:
4245
4246 @example
4247 foreach name [target names] @{
4248 set y [$name cget -endian]
4249 set z [$name cget -type]
4250 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4251 $x $name $y $z]
4252 @}
4253 @end example
4254 @end deffn
4255
4256 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4257 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4258 Displays the current target state:
4259 @code{debug-running},
4260 @code{halted},
4261 @code{reset},
4262 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4263 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4264 @end deffn
4265
4266 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4267 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4268 currently associated with this target.
4269 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4270 @end deffn
4271
4272 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4273 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4274 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4275 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4276 @end deffn
4277
4278 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4279 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4280 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4281 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4282 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4283 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4284 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4285 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4286 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4287 @end deffn
4288
4289 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4290 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4291 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4292 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4293 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4294 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4295 @end deffn
4296
4297 @anchor{targetevents}
4298 @section Target Events
4299 @cindex target events
4300 @cindex events
4301 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4302 For example:
4303 @itemize @bullet
4304 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4305 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4306 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4307 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4308 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4309 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4310 to set up system clocks or
4311 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4312 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4313 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4314 @end itemize
4315
4316 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4317 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4318 @command{target create ... -event}.
4319
4320 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4321 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4322 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4323
4324 @example
4325 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4326 echo "Reset..."
4327 reset halt
4328 @}
4329 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4330 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4331 echo "Reset..."
4332 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4333 # we need a reset init.
4334 reset init
4335 @}
4336 @end example
4337
4338 The following target events are defined:
4339
4340 @itemize @bullet
4341 @item @b{debug-halted}
4342 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4343 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4344 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4345 @item @b{early-halted}
4346 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4347 @item @b{examine-start}
4348 @* Before target examine is called.
4349 @item @b{examine-end}
4350 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4351 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4352 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4353 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4354 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4355 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4356 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4357 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4358 @* When GDB disconnects
4359 @item @b{gdb-end}
4360 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4361 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4362 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4363 @code{reset init})
4364 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4365 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4366 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4367 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4368 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4369 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4370 @item @b{gdb-start}
4371 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4372 @item @b{halted}
4373 @* The target has halted
4374 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4375 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4376 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4377 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4378 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4379 @item @b{reset-assert}
4380 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4381 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4382 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4383 it instead of asserting SRST.
4384 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4385 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4386 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4387 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4388 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4389 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4390 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4391 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4392 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4393 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4394 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4395 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4396 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4397 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4398 released on the scan chain.
4399 @item @b{reset-end}
4400 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4401 @ignore
4402 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4403 @* Currently not used
4404 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4405 @* Currently not used
4406 @end ignore
4407 @item @b{reset-init}
4408 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4409 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4410
4411 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4412 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4413 multiplexing, and so on.
4414 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4415 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4416 @item @b{reset-start}
4417 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4418 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4419
4420 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4421 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4422 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4423 @ignore
4424 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4425 @* Currently not used
4426 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4427 @* Currently not used
4428 @end ignore
4429 @item @b{resume-start}
4430 @* Before any target is resumed
4431 @item @b{resume-end}
4432 @* After all targets have resumed
4433 @item @b{resumed}
4434 @* Target has resumed
4435 @item @b{trace-config}
4436 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4437 @end itemize
4438
4439 @node Flash Commands
4440 @chapter Flash Commands
4441
4442 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4443 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4444 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4445 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4446 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4447 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4448 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4449 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4450 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4451
4452 Flash Steps:
4453 @enumerate
4454 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4455 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4456 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4457 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4458 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4459 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4460 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4461 @item GDB Flashing
4462 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4463 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4464 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4465 @end enumerate
4466
4467 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4468 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4469 so that it can't boot.
4470 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4471 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4472
4473 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4474 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4475 @cindex flash configuration
4476
4477 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4478 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4479 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4480 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4481 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4482 see the driver-specific documentation.
4483
4484 @itemize @bullet
4485 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4486 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4487 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4488 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4489 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4490 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4491 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4492 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4493 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4494 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4495 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4496 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4497 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4498 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4499 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4500 commands to the flash controller.
4501 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4502 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4503 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4504 for more information.
4505 @end itemize
4506 @quotation Note
4507 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4508 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4509 @end quotation
4510 @end deffn
4511
4512 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4513 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4514 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4515 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4516 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4517 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4518 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4519 @end deffn
4520
4521 @deffn Command {flash list}
4522 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4523 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4524 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4525 @end deffn
4526
4527 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4528 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4529 depends on the flash type.
4530 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4531 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4532 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4533 but most don't bother.
4534 @end deffn
4535
4536 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4537 @cindex flash erasing
4538 @cindex flash reading
4539 @cindex flash writing
4540 @cindex flash programming
4541 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4542
4543 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4544 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4545 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4546 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4547 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4548
4549 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4550 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4551 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4552 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4553 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4554
4555 @quotation Note
4556 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4557 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4558 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4559 back to a flash bank.
4560 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4561 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4562 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4563 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4564 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4565 @end quotation
4566
4567 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4568 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4569 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4570 disabled first.
4571 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4572 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4573 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4574
4575 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4576 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4577 up to and including @var{last}.
4578 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4579 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4580 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4581 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4582 @end deffn
4583
4584 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4585 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4586 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4587 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4588 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4589 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4590 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4591 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4592 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4593 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4594 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4595 before erase starts.
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4599 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4600 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4601 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4602 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4603 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4604 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4605 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4606 before issuing this command.
4607 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4608 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4609 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4610 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4611 @end deffn
4612 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4613
4614 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4615 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4616 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4617 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4618 @end deffn
4619
4620 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4621 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4622 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4623 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4624 @end deffn
4625
4626 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4627 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4628 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4629 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4630 @end deffn
4631
4632 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4633 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4634 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4635 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4636 to the base address for each section in the image.
4637 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4638 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4639 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4640 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4641 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4642 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4643 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4644 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4645 each image section.
4646
4647 @quotation Warning
4648 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4649 data you want to preserve.
4650 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4651 sections might be erased with no notice.
4652 @itemize
4653 @item
4654 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4655 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4656 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4657 @item
4658 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4659 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4660 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4661 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4662 @end itemize
4663 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4664 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4665 @end quotation
4666
4667 @end deffn
4668
4669 @section Other Flash commands
4670 @cindex flash protection
4671
4672 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4673 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4674 and display that status.
4675 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4676 @end deffn
4677
4678 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4679 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4680 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4681
4682 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4683 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4684 and possibly stale information.
4685 @end deffn
4686
4687 @anchor{flashprotect}
4688 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4689 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4690 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4691 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4692 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4693 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4694 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4695 @end deffn
4696
4697 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4698 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4699 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4700 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4701 @end deffn
4702
4703 @anchor{program}
4704 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4705 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4706 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4707 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4708 @end deffn
4709
4710 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4711 @section Flash Driver List
4712 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4713 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4714 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4715
4716 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4717 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4718 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4719
4720 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4721
4722 @itemize
4723 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4724 @end itemize
4725
4726 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4727 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4728 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4729 @example
4730 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4731 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4732 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4733 @end example
4734 @end deffn
4735
4736 @subsection External Flash
4737
4738 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4739 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4740 @cindex CFI
4741 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4742 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4743 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4744 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4745 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4746 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4747 configure a bus and its timings), or
4748 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4749 on the flash chip.
4750 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4751 speed up operation.
4752
4753 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4754
4755 @itemize
4756 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4757 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4758 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4759 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4760 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4761 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4762 @end itemize
4763
4764 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4765 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4766
4767 @example
4768 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4770 @end example
4771
4772 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4773 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4774 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4775
4776 @example
4777 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4778 @end example
4779
4780 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4781 @end deffn
4782
4783 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4784 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4785 @cindex SPI
4786 @cindex jtagspi
4787 @cindex bscan_spi
4788 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4789 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4790 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4791 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4792 accessed through JTAG.
4793
4794 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4795 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4796 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4797 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4798 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4799 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4800
4801 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4802 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4803 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4804 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4805 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4806 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4807 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4808 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4809
4810 @itemize
4811 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4812 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4813 @var{USER1} instruction.
4814 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4815 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4816 @end itemize
4817
4818 @example
4819 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4820 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4821 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4822 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4823 @end example
4824 @end deffn
4825
4826 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4827 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4828 @cindex SPIFI
4829 @cindex lpcspifi
4830 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4831 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4832 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4833
4834 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4835 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4836 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4837 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4838 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4839
4840 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4841 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4842 are configured by the driver.
4843
4844 @example
4845 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4846 @end example
4847
4848 @end deffn
4849
4850 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4851 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4852 @cindex SMI
4853 @cindex stmsmi
4854 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4855 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4856 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4857 SPI flash devices.
4858 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4859 flash devices can be connected.
4860
4861 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4862 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4863 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4864 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4865 the flash content.
4866
4867 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4868 to identify the memory bank.
4869 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4870 flash size, are detected automatically.
4871
4872 @example
4873 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4874 @end example
4875
4876 @end deffn
4877
4878 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4879 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4880 Microcontroller platform.
4881
4882 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4883 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4884
4885 @example
4886 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4887 @end example
4888
4889 @end deffn
4890
4891 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4892
4893 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4894 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4895 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4896 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4897 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4898 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4899
4900 @example
4901 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4902 @end example
4903 @end deffn
4904
4905 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
4906 @cindex ambiqmicro
4907 @cindex apollo
4908 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
4909 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4910 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
4911 with the target using SWD.
4912
4913 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
4914 the device class of the MCU.
4915 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
4916 to set up the flash banks.
4917 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
4918 sizes of an Apollo chip.
4919
4920 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
4921 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
4922 and the second bank starts after the first.
4923
4924 @example
4925 # Flash bank 0
4926 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4927 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
4928 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4929 @end example
4930
4931 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
4932 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
4933 are available to the user.
4934
4935 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
4936
4937 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
4938 Erase entire bank.
4939 @end deffn
4940 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
4941 Erase device pages.
4942 @end deffn
4943 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
4944 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
4945 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
4946 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
4947 the flash.
4948 @end deffn
4949 @end deffn
4950
4951 @anchor{at91samd}
4952 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4953 @cindex at91samd
4954 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
4955 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
4956 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4957
4958 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4959 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4960 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4961 processor to be halted.
4962 @end deffn
4963
4964 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4965 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4966 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4967 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4968 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4969 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4970
4971 @example
4972 at91samd set-security enable
4973 @end example
4974 @end deffn
4975
4976 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4977 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4978 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4979 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4980 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4981 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4982 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4983 in order to disable this feature.
4984
4985 @example
4986 at91samd eeprom
4987 at91samd eeprom 1024
4988 @end example
4989 @end deffn
4990
4991 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4992 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4993 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4994 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4995 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4996 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4997
4998 @example
4999 at91samd bootloader
5000 at91samd bootloader 16384
5001 @end example
5002 @end deffn
5003
5004 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5005 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5006 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5007 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5008 @end deffn
5009
5010 @end deffn
5011
5012 @anchor{at91sam3}
5013 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5014 @cindex at91sam3
5015 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5016 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5017 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5018 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5019 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5020 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5021 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5022 chips are confirmed.}
5023
5024 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5025 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5026 the following fixed locations:
5027
5028 @example
5029 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5030 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5031 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5032 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5033 @end example
5034
5035 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5036 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5037 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5038
5039 @itemize
5040 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5041 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5042 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5043 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5044 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5045 @end itemize
5046
5047 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5048
5049 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5050 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5051 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5052 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5053 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5054 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5055 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5056
5057 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5058 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5059 @end deffn
5060
5061 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5062 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5063 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5064 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5065 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5066 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5067 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5068 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5069 @end deffn
5070
5071 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5072 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5073 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5074 @end deffn
5075 @end deffn
5076
5077 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5078 @cindex at91sam4
5079 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5080 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5081 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5082 @end deffn
5083
5084 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5085 @cindex at91sam4l
5086 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5087 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5088 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5089
5090 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5091 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5092 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5093 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5094 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5095 @end deffn
5096 @end deffn
5097
5098 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5099 @cindex atsamv
5100 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5101 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5102 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5103 @end deffn
5104
5105 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5106 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5107 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5108 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5109 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5110
5111 @example
5112 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5113 @end example
5114
5115 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5116 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5117
5118 @itemize
5119 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5120 @item @var{banks}
5121 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5122 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5123 @item @var{pages_size}
5124 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5125 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5126 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5127 @end itemize
5128
5129 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5130 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5131 will be autoconfigured.
5132 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5133
5134 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5135 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5136 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5137 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5138 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5139
5140 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5141 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5142 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5143 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5144 are not truly general purpose).
5145 @quotation Note
5146 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5147 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5148 @end quotation
5149 @end deffn
5150 @end deffn
5151
5152 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5153 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5154 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5155 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5156 @end deffn
5157
5158 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5159 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5160 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5161 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5162 autoconfigures itself.
5163 @example
5164 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5165 @end example
5166 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5167 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5168 this via the following command:
5169 @example
5170 efm32 debuglock num
5171 @end example
5172 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5173 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5174 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5175 supported.}
5176 @end deffn
5177
5178 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5179 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5180 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5181 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5182 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5183 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5184 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5185
5186 @example
5187 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5188 @end example
5189 @end deffn
5190
5191 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5192 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5193 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5194 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5195 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5196 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5197 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5198 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5199 characters) ignored.
5200
5201 @example
5202 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5203 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5204 @end example
5205 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5206 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5207 @end deffn
5208
5209 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5210 @cindex kinetis
5211 Kx and KLx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5212 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5213 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5214 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5215
5216 @example
5217 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5218 @end example
5219
5220 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5221 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5222 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5223 set by 'flash protect' command.
5224 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5225 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5226 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5227 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5228 with the rest of a flash image.
5229 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5230 @end deffn
5231
5232 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5233 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5234 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5238 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5239 @end deffn
5240
5241 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5242 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5243 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5244 @end deffn
5245
5246 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5247 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5248 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5249 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5250 command completes.
5251 @end deffn
5252
5253 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5254 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5255 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5256 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5257 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5258
5259 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5260 Program Partition command.
5261
5262 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5263 Reset the device after partition setting.
5264
5265 Show partition size:
5266 @example
5267 kinetis nvm_partition info
5268 @end example
5269
5270 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5271 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5272 @example
5273 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5274 @end example
5275
5276 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5277 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5278 @example
5279 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5280 @end example
5281 @end deffn
5282
5283 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5284 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5285 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5289 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5290 Command disables watchdog timer.
5291 @end deffn
5292 @end deffn
5293
5294 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5295 @cindex kinetis_ke
5296 KE members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5297 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5298 the KE family and sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5299 autoconfigures itself.
5300
5301 @example
5302 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5303 @end example
5304
5305 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5306 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5307 @end deffn
5308
5309 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5310 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5311 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5312 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5313 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5314 @end deffn
5315
5316 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5317 Command disables watchdog timer.
5318 @end deffn
5319 @end deffn
5320
5321 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5322 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5323 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5324 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5325 microcontroller families from NXP.
5326
5327 @quotation Note
5328 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5329 driver:
5330 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5331 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5332 @end quotation
5333
5334 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5335 which must appear in the following order:
5336
5337 @itemize
5338 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5339 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5340 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5341 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5342 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5343 LPC43x[2357])
5344 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5345 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5346 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5347 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5348 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5349 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5350 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5351 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5352 at which the core is running
5353 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5354 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5355 @quotation Note
5356 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5357 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5358 However, if you do provide it,
5359 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5360 @end quotation
5361 @end itemize
5362
5363 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5364
5365 @example
5366 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5367 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5368 @end example
5369
5370 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5371 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5372 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5373 @end deffn
5374 @end deffn
5375
5376 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5377 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5378 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5379 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5380 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5381 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5382
5383 @example
5384 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5385 @end example
5386 @end deffn
5387
5388 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5389 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5390 from NXP.
5391
5392 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5393 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5394 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5395 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5396 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5397 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5398 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5399 you start the PLL.
5400
5401 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5402
5403 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5404 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5405 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5406
5407 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5408 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5409 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5410 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5411 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5412 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5413 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5414
5415 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5416 @example
5417 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5418 @end example
5419
5420 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5421 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5422 @code{flash banks} command.
5423
5424 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5425 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5426 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5427 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5428 a known signature.
5429 Example:
5430 @example
5431 lpc2900 signature 0
5432 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5433 @end example
5434 @end deffn
5435
5436 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5437 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5438 saves it to a file in binary format.
5439 Example:
5440 @example
5441 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5442 @end example
5443 @end deffn
5444
5445 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5446 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5447 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5448 command:
5449
5450 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5451 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5452 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5453 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5454
5455 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5456 Example:
5457 @example
5458 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5459 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5460 @end example
5461 @end deffn
5462
5463 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5464 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5465 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5466 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5467 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5468 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5469 912 bytes.
5470 @quotation Attention
5471 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5472 @end quotation
5473 Example:
5474 @example
5475 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5476 @end example
5477 @end deffn
5478
5479 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5480 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5481 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5482 after the next power cycle.
5483 @quotation Attention
5484 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5485 @end quotation
5486 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5487 Example:
5488 @example
5489 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5490 flash info 0
5491 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5492 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5493 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5494 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5495 @end example
5496 @end deffn
5497
5498 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5499 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5500 effective after the next power cycle.
5501 @quotation Attention
5502 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5503 @end quotation
5504 Examples:
5505 @example
5506 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5507 @end example
5508 @end deffn
5509 @end deffn
5510
5511 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5512 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5513 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5514 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5515
5516 @example
5517 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5518 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5519 @end example
5520
5521 @itemize @bullet
5522 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5523 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5524 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5525 @end itemize
5526
5527 Example usage:
5528 @example
5529 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5530 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5531 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5532 @} else @{
5533 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5534 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5535 @}
5536 @end example
5537 @end deffn
5538
5539 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5540 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5541 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5542 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5543 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5544 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5545 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5546 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5547 also have division into regions: main and info.
5548 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5549 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5550
5551 @example
5552 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5553 @end example
5554
5555 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5556
5557 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5558 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5559 @end deffn
5560
5561 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5562 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5563 @end deffn
5564
5565 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5566 Erase all userflash including info region.
5567 @end deffn
5568
5569 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5570 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5571 @end deffn
5572
5573 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5574 Check sectors protect.
5575 @end deffn
5576
5577 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5578 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5579 @end deffn
5580
5581 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5582 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5583 @end deffn
5584
5585 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5586 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5587 @end deffn
5588
5589 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5590 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5591 @end deffn
5592
5593 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5594 Show information about flash driver.
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @end deffn
5598
5599 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5600 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5601 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5602
5603 @example
5604 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5605 @end example
5606
5607 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5608
5609 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5610 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5611 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5612 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5613 code.
5614 @end deffn
5615
5616 @end deffn
5617
5618 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5619 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5620 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5621
5622 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5623 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5624 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5625 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5626
5627 @example
5628 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5629 @end example
5630 @end deffn
5631
5632 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5633 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5634 and integrate flash memory.
5635
5636 @example
5637 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5638 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5639 @end example
5640
5641 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5642 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5643 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5644 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5645 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5646 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5647 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5648 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5649 @end deffn
5650 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5651 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5652 This will remove any Code Protection.
5653 @end deffn
5654 @end deffn
5655
5656 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5657 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5658 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5659 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5660 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5661
5662 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5663 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5664
5665 @example
5666 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5667 @end example
5668
5669 psoc4-specific commands
5670 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5671 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5672
5673 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5674 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5675
5676 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5677 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5678 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5679
5680 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5681 @end deffn
5682
5683 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5684 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5685
5686 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5687 @end deffn
5688 @end deffn
5689
5690 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5691 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5692 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5693 and SWD interface.
5694 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5695 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5696
5697 @example
5698 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5699 @end example
5700
5701 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5702
5703 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5704 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5705 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5706 @end deffn
5707
5708 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5709 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5710 @end deffn
5711 @end deffn
5712
5713 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5714 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5715 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5716 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5717 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5718 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5719 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5720 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5721
5722 @example
5723 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5724 @end example
5725
5726 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5727 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5728 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5729 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5730 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5731 disabled.
5732
5733 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5734 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5735 @quotation Warning
5736 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5737 applied to all of them.
5738 @end quotation
5739 @end deffn
5740 @end deffn
5741
5742 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5743 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5744 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5745 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5746 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5747
5748 @example
5749 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5750 @end example
5751
5752 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5753 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5754 the flash driver.
5755
5756 @example
5757 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5758 @end example
5759
5760 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5761 as per the following example.
5762 @example
5763 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5764 @end example
5765
5766 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5767 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5768 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5769 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5770 are defined:
5771
5772 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5773 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5774 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5778 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5779 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5780 @end deffn
5781
5782 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5783 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5784 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5785 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5786 @end deffn
5787
5788 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5789 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5790 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5791 @end deffn
5792 @end deffn
5793
5794 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5795 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5796 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
5797 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5798 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5799
5800 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5801 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5802 the flash driver.
5803
5804 @example
5805 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5806 @end example
5807
5808 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5809
5810 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5811 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5812 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5813 @end deffn
5814
5815 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5816 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5817 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5818 @end deffn
5819
5820 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
5821 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1.
5822 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5823 @end deffn
5824
5825 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
5826 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
5827 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
5828 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, user_options a
5829 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, boot_addr0 and boot_addr1
5830 two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
5831 @end deffn
5832 @end deffn
5833
5834 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5835 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5836 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5837 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5838 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5839
5840 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5841 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5842 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5843 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5844 second bank.
5845
5846 @example
5847 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5848 @end example
5849
5850 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5851
5852 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5853 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5854 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5855 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5856 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5857 @end deffn
5858 @end deffn
5859
5860 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5861 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5862 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5863 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5864 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5865
5866 @example
5867 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5868 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5869 @end example
5870
5871 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5872 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5873 for the specified flash bank.
5874 @end deffn
5875 @end deffn
5876
5877 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5878 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5879 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5880 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5881 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5882
5883 @example
5884 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5885 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5886 @end example
5887
5888 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5889 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5890 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5891
5892 @itemize @bullet
5893 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5894 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5895 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5896 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5897 @end itemize
5898 @end deffn
5899
5900 @end deffn
5901
5902 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5903 @cindex str9xpec
5904
5905 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5906 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5907 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5908 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5909
5910 Here is some background info to help
5911 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5912 the str9:
5913 @enumerate
5914 @item
5915 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5916 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5917 @item
5918 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5919 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5920 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5921 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5922 @end enumerate
5923
5924 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5925 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5926 configured for flash bank 0.
5927 @example
5928 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5929 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5930 jtag_reset 0 1
5931 # turn off target polling
5932 poll off
5933 # disable str9 core
5934 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5935 # read option bytes
5936 str9xpec options_read 0
5937 # re-enable str9 core
5938 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5939 poll on
5940 reset halt
5941 @end example
5942 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5943 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5944 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5945 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5946
5947 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5948
5949 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5950 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5951 @end deffn
5952
5953 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5954 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5955 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5956 @end deffn
5957
5958 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5959 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5960 erase the device.
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5964 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5965 @end deffn
5966
5967 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5968 Configure str9 boot bank.
5969 @end deffn
5970
5971 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5972 Configure str9 lvd source.
5973 @end deffn
5974
5975 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5976 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5977 @end deffn
5978
5979 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5980 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5981 @end deffn
5982
5983 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5984 Read str9 option bytes.
5985 @end deffn
5986
5987 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5988 Write str9 option bytes.
5989 @end deffn
5990
5991 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5992 unlock str9 device.
5993 @end deffn
5994
5995 @end deffn
5996
5997 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5998 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5999 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6000 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6001
6002 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6003
6004 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6005 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6006 @end deffn
6007
6008 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6009 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6010 @end deffn
6011
6012 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6013 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6014 the flash clock.
6015 @end deffn
6016 @end deffn
6017
6018 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6019 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6020 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6021 @end deffn
6022
6023 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6024 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6025 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6026
6027 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6028
6029 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6030 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6031 @end deffn
6032
6033 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6034 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6035 @end deffn
6036
6037 @end deffn
6038
6039 @section NAND Flash Commands
6040 @cindex NAND
6041
6042 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6043 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6044 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6045
6046 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6047 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6048 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6049 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6050 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6051 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6052
6053 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6054 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6055 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6056 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6057 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6058 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6059 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6060 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6061 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6062 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6063
6064 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6065 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6066 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6067 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6068 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6069 every 512 bytes of data.
6070
6071 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6072 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6073 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6074 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6075 ECC mode is used.
6076
6077 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6078 @enumerate
6079 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6080 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6081 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6082 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6083 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6084 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6085 to access that device.
6086 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6087 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6088 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6089 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6090 de-brick a board.
6091 @end enumerate
6092
6093 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6094 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6095 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6096 are only 32 bits wide.
6097 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6098 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6099 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6100 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6101
6102 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6103 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6104 @cindex NAND configuration
6105
6106 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6107 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6108 OpenOCD has initialized.
6109
6110 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6111 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6112 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6113 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6114 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6115 they were a single (larger) device.
6116 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6117 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6118
6119 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6120 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6121 configuration files, not interactively.
6122
6123 @itemize @bullet
6124 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6125 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6126 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6127 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6128 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6129 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6130 commands to the NAND controller.
6131 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6132 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6133 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6134 for more information.
6135 @end itemize
6136 @end deffn
6137
6138 @deffn Command {nand list}
6139 Prints a summary of each device declared
6140 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6141 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6142 @example
6143 > nand list
6144 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6145 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6146 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6147 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6148 >
6149 @end example
6150 @end deffn
6151
6152 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6153 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6154 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6155 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6156 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6157 it with most other NAND commands.
6158 @end deffn
6159
6160 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6161
6162 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6163 @cindex NAND reading
6164 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6165 starting at the specified offset.
6166 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6167
6168 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6169 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6170
6171 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6172 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6173 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6174
6175 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6176 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6177 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6178 method which handled that error correction.
6179
6180 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6181 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6182 @itemize @bullet
6183 @item no oob_* parameter
6184 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6185 @item @code{oob_raw}
6186 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6187 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6188 spare areas associated with each data page.
6189 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6190 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6191 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6192 @item @code{oob_only}
6193 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6194 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6195 spare areas associated with each data page.
6196 @end itemize
6197 @end deffn
6198
6199 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6200 @cindex NAND erasing
6201 @cindex NAND programming
6202 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6203 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6204 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6205 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6206 If those parameters are not specified,
6207 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6208 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6209
6210 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6211 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6212 block marker.
6213 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6214 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6218 @cindex NAND writing
6219 @cindex NAND programming
6220 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6221 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6222 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6223 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6224
6225 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6226 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6227
6228 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6229 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6230 past the end of the device.
6231 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6232 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6233 if that's being written.)
6234
6235 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6236 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6237 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6238
6239 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6240 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6241 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6242 @itemize @bullet
6243 @item no oob_* parameter
6244 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6245 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6246 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6247 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6248 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6249 @item @code{oob_only}
6250 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6251 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6252 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6253 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6254 @item @code{oob_raw}
6255 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6256 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6257 un-altered OOB.
6258 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6259 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6260 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6261 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6262 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6263 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6264 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6265 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6266 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6267 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6268 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6269 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6270 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6271 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6272 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6273 @end itemize
6274 @end deffn
6275
6276 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6277 @cindex NAND verification
6278 @cindex NAND programming
6279 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6280 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6281 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6282
6283 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6284 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6285
6286 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6287 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6288 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6289 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6290 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6291
6292 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6293 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6294 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6295
6296 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6297 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6298 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6299 be removed in a future release.
6300 @end deffn
6301
6302 @subsection Other NAND commands
6303 @cindex NAND other commands
6304
6305 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6306 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6307 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6308 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6309 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6310 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6311 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6312 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6313
6314 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6315 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6316 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6317 @end deffn
6318
6319 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6320 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6321 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6322 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6323 status for each block.
6324 @end deffn
6325
6326 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6327 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6328 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6329
6330 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6331 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6332 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6333 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6334 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6335
6336 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6337 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6338 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6339 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6340 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6341 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6342 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6343 @end deffn
6344
6345 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6346 @subsection NAND Driver List
6347 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6348 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6349 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6350
6351 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6352 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6353 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6354 address of the ECC controller.
6355 @example
6356 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6357 @end example
6358 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6359 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6360 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6361 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6362 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6363 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6364 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6365 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6366 @end deffn
6367 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6368 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6369 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6370 @end deffn
6371
6372 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6373 properly configured for input or output.
6374 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6375 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6376 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6377 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6378 @end deffn
6379 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6380 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6381 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6382 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6383 @end deffn
6384 @end deffn
6385
6386 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6387 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6388 chips from Texas Instruments.
6389 It takes three extra parameters:
6390 address of the NAND chip;
6391 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6392 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6393 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6394 @example
6395 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6396 @end example
6397 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6398 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6399 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6400 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6401 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6402 @end deffn
6403
6404 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6405 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6406 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6407 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6408 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6409 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6410 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6411 @end deffn
6412
6413 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6414 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6415 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6416 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6417 @end deffn
6418 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6419
6420 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6421 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6422 should work for this chip aswell.
6423 @end deffn
6424
6425 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6426 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6427 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6428 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6429 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6430 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6431 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6432 @example
6433 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6434 @end example
6435 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6436 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6437 without parameter query status.
6438 @end deffn
6439 @end deffn
6440
6441 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6442 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6443 parameter: the address of the controller.
6444 @example
6445 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6446 @end example
6447 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6448 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6449 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6450 change any behavior.
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6454 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6455 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6456 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6457 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6458 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6459 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6460 specialized commands.
6461 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6462 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6463 change any behavior.
6464 @end deffn
6465
6466 @section mFlash
6467
6468 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6469 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6470
6471 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6472 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6473 address @var{base}.
6474 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6475 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6476
6477 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6478
6479 @example
6480 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6481 @end example
6482
6483 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6484
6485 @example
6486 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6487 @end example
6488 @end deffn
6489
6490 @subsection mFlash commands
6491 @cindex mFlash commands
6492
6493 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6494 Configure mflash PLL.
6495 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6496 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6497 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6498 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6499 @end deffn
6500
6501 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6502 Configure bootable option.
6503 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6504 (4kB) for boot.
6505 @end deffn
6506
6507 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6508 Configure storage information.
6509 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6510 written.
6511 @end deffn
6512
6513 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6514 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6515 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6519 Probe mflash.
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6523 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6524 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6525 @end deffn
6526
6527 @node Flash Programming
6528 @chapter Flash Programming
6529
6530 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6531 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6532 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6533
6534 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6535 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6536
6537 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6538 @enumerate
6539 @item 'init' is executed.
6540 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6541 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6542 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6543 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6544 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6545 @end enumerate
6546
6547 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6548
6549 @example
6550 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6551 # are optional parameters
6552 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6553 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6554
6555 # binary files need the flash address passing
6556 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6557 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6558 @end example
6559
6560 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6561 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6562 @cindex PLD
6563 @cindex FPGA
6564
6565 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6566 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6567 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6568 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6569 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6570 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6571 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6572
6573 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6574
6575 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6576 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6577 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6578
6579 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6580 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6581
6582 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6583 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6584 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6585 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6586 behavior.
6587 @end deffn
6588
6589 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6590 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6591 @end deffn
6592
6593 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6594 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6595 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6596 @end deffn
6597
6598 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6599
6600 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6601 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6602 that particular type of PLD.
6603
6604 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6605 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6606 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6607
6608 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6609 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6610 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6611
6612 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6613 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6614 for FPGA @var{num}.
6615 @end deffn
6616 @end deffn
6617
6618 @node General Commands
6619 @chapter General Commands
6620 @cindex commands
6621
6622 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6623 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6624 commands are documented elsewhere.
6625
6626 Intent:
6627 @itemize @bullet
6628 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6629 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6630 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6631 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6632
6633 @item @b{From the human}
6634 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6635 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6636
6637 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6638 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6639 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6640
6641 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6642 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6643 port is 5555.
6644 @end itemize
6645
6646
6647 @section Server Commands
6648
6649 @deffn {Command} exit
6650 Exits the current telnet session.
6651 @end deffn
6652
6653 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6654 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6655 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6656 Not every command provides helptext.
6657
6658 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6659 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6660 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6661 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6665 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6666 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6667 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6668 Useful in connection with script files
6669 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6670 @end deffn
6671
6672 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6673 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6674 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6675 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6676 @end deffn
6677
6678 @anchor{debuglevel}
6679 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6680 @cindex message level
6681 Display debug level.
6682 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6683 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6684 Level 0 is error messages only;
6685 level 1 adds warnings;
6686 level 2 adds informational messages;
6687 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6688 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6689 the command line along with the location of that log
6690 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6691 @xref{Running}.
6692 @end deffn
6693
6694 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6695 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6696 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6697 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6698 @example
6699 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6700 @end example
6701 @end deffn
6702
6703 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6704 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6705 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6706 @end deffn
6707
6708 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6709 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6710 @end deffn
6711
6712 @deffn Command bindto [name]
6713 Specify address by name on which to listen for incoming TCP/IP connections.
6714 By default, OpenOCD will listen on all available interfaces.
6715 @end deffn
6716
6717 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6718 @section Target State handling
6719 @cindex reset
6720 @cindex halt
6721 @cindex target initialization
6722
6723 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6724 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6725 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6726 a current target which is used to perform the
6727 various operations. The current target may be changed
6728 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6729 target which should become current.
6730
6731 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6732 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6733 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6734 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6735 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6736
6737 @emph{With no arguments}:
6738 list all available registers for the current target,
6739 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6740 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6741 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6742 are flagged as such.
6743
6744 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6745 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6746 bypassing any internal cache.
6747
6748 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6749 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6750 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6751 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6752 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6753 relevant module will flush such values.
6754
6755 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6756 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6757
6758 @example
6759 > reg
6760 ===== ARM registers
6761 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6762 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6763 (2) r2 (/32)
6764 ...
6765 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6766 >
6767 @end example
6768 @end deffn
6769
6770 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6771 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6772 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6773 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6774 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6775 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6776 (and enter debug mode).
6777 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6778
6779 @quotation Warning
6780 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6781 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6782 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6783 power mode by gating the core clock;
6784 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6785
6786 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6787 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6788 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6789 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6790 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6791 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6792
6793 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6794 work with a JTAG debugger.
6795 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6796 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6797 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6798 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6799 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6800 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6801 @end quotation
6802
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn Command resume [address]
6806 Resume the target at its current code position,
6807 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6808 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6809 @end deffn
6810
6811 @deffn Command step [address]
6812 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6813 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @anchor{resetcommand}
6817 @deffn Command reset
6818 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6819 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6820 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6821 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6822 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6823 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6824
6825 The optional parameter specifies what should
6826 happen after the reset.
6827 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6828 The other options will not work on all systems.
6829 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6830
6831 @itemize @minus
6832 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6833 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6834 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6835 @end itemize
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6839 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6840 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6841 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6842 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6843 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6844 state.
6845 @end deffn
6846
6847 @section I/O Utilities
6848
6849 These commands are available when
6850 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6851 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6852 notably the ZY1000.
6853 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6854
6855 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6856
6857 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6858 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6859 the text file @file{filename}.
6860 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6861 The last string is followed by a newline.
6862 @end deffn
6863
6864 @deffn Command cat filename
6865 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6866 @end deffn
6867
6868 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6869 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6870 into @file{dest_filename}.
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @deffn Command ip
6874 @emph{No description provided.}
6875 @end deffn
6876
6877 @deffn Command ls
6878 @emph{No description provided.}
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn Command mac
6882 @emph{No description provided.}
6883 @end deffn
6884
6885 @deffn Command meminfo
6886 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6887 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6888 @end deffn
6889
6890 @deffn Command peek
6891 @emph{No description provided.}
6892 @end deffn
6893
6894 @deffn Command poke
6895 @emph{No description provided.}
6896 @end deffn
6897
6898 @deffn Command rm filename
6899 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6900 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6901 @end deffn
6902
6903 @deffn Command trunc filename
6904 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6905 @end deffn
6906
6907 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6908 @section Memory access commands
6909 @cindex memory access
6910
6911 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6912 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6913 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6914 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6915
6916 @enumerate
6917 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6918 to change the current target.
6919 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6920 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6921 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6922 @end enumerate
6923
6924 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6925 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6926 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6927 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6928 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6929 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6930 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6931 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6932 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6933 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6934 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6935 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6936 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6940 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6941 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6942 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6943 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6944 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6945 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6946 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6947 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6948 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6949 @end deffn
6950
6951 @anchor{imageaccess}
6952 @section Image loading commands
6953 @cindex image loading
6954 @cindex image dumping
6955
6956 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6957 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6958 binary file named @var{filename}.
6959 @end deffn
6960
6961 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6962 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6963 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6964 @end deffn
6965
6966 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6967 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6968 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6969 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6970 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6971 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6972 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6973 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6974 separately.
6975 @end deffn
6976
6977 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6978 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6979 The file format may optionally be specified
6980 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6981 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6982 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6983 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6984 @example
6985 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6986 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6987 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6988 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6989 $address $length
6990 @}
6991 @end example
6992 @end deffn
6993
6994 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6995 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6996 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6997 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6998 The file format may optionally be specified
6999 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7000 @end deffn
7001
7002 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7003 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7004 The file format may optionally be specified
7005 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7006 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7007 @end deffn
7008
7009 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7010 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7011 The file format may optionally be specified
7012 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7013 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016
7017 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7018 @cindex breakpoint
7019 @cindex watchpoint
7020
7021 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7022 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7023 watchpoints.
7024 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7025
7026 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7027 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7028 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7029 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7030 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7031 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7032
7033 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7034 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7038 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7042 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7043 @end deffn
7044
7045 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7046 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7047 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7048 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7049 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7050 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7051 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7052 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7053 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @section Misc Commands
7057
7058 @cindex profiling
7059 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7060 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7061 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7062 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7063 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7064 limit the address range.
7065 @end deffn
7066
7067 @deffn Command {version}
7068 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7072 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7073 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7074 @end deffn
7075
7076 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7077 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7078 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7079 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7080
7081 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7082 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7083 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7084 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7085
7086 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7087 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7088 @cindex tracing
7089 @cindex ETM
7090 @cindex ETB
7091
7092 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7093 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7094 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7095
7096 @itemize
7097 @item
7098 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7099 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7100 supports such an interface.
7101 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7102 and trace port support.)
7103 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7104 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7105 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7106 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7107 in the board-specific configuration file.
7108 @item
7109 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7110 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7111 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7112 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7113 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7114 @end itemize
7115
7116 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7117
7118 @quotation Issues
7119 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7120 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7121
7122 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7123 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7124 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7125 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7126 dummy trace port driver}.
7127
7128 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7129 as well as tracing only during specific states
7130 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7131
7132 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7133 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7134 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7135 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7136 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7137
7138 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7139 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7140 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7141 this original style of JTAG access.
7142 @end quotation
7143
7144 @subsection ETM Configuration
7145 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7146
7147 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7148 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7149 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7150
7151 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7152 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7153 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7154 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7155 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7156 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7157 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7158 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7159 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7160
7161 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7162 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7163 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7164
7165 @quotation Warning
7166 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7167 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7168 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7169 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7170 @end quotation
7171
7172 @quotation Note
7173 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7174 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7175 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7176 what CPU activities are traced.
7177 @end quotation
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn Command {etm info}
7181 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7182 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7183 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7184 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7185 @end deffn
7186
7187 @deffn Command {etm status}
7188 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7189 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7190 Did trace data overflow?
7191 Was it triggered?
7192 @end deffn
7193
7194 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7195 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7196 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7197 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7198 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7199
7200 @itemize
7201 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7202 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7203 The value is one of
7204 @option{none} (save nothing),
7205 @option{data} (save data),
7206 @option{address} (save addresses),
7207 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7208 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7209 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7210 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7211 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7212 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7213 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7214 trace stream without an image of the code.
7215 @end itemize
7216 @end deffn
7217
7218 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7219 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7220 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7221 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7222 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7223
7224 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7225 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7226 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7230
7231 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7232 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7233 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7234
7235 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7236 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7237 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7238 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7239 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7240 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7241 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7242
7243 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7244
7245 @itemize
7246 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7247 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7248 for instruction access within that function's body.
7249 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7250 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7251 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7252 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7253 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7254 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7255 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7256 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7257 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7258 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7259 @item @emph{... more}
7260 @end itemize
7261
7262 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7263 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7264
7265 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7266 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7267 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7268 @end deffn
7269
7270 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7271 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7272 @end deffn
7273
7274 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7275 Opens an image file.
7276 @end deffn
7277
7278 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7279 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn Command {etm start}
7283 Starts trace data collection.
7284 @end deffn
7285
7286 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7287 Stops trace data collection.
7288 @end deffn
7289
7290 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7291 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7292
7293 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7294
7295 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7296 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7297 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7298 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7299 any trace data collection.}
7300 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7301 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7302 @end deffn
7303 @end deffn
7304
7305 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7306 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7307 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7308 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7309 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7310 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7311 @end deffn
7312 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7313 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7314 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7315 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7316 trace trigger becomes active.
7317
7318 @itemize
7319 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7320 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7321 afterwards.
7322 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7323 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7324 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7325 what caused that event to happen.
7326 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7327 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7328 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7329 how the event caused trouble.
7330 @end itemize
7331 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7332 @end deffn
7333
7334 @end deffn
7335
7336 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7337 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7338 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7339 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7340 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7341
7342 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7343 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7344
7345 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7346 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7347 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7348 @end deffn
7349
7350 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7351 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7352 @end deffn
7353
7354 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7355 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7356 @end deffn
7357 @end deffn
7358
7359
7360 @section Generic ARM
7361 @cindex ARM
7362
7363 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7364 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7365 commands that may be available.
7366
7367 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7368 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7369 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7370 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7371 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7372 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7373 @end deffn
7374
7375 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7376 @cindex disassemble
7377 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7378 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7379 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7380 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7381 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7382 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7383 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7384
7385 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7386 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7387 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7388 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7389 with a handful of exceptions.
7390 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7394 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7395 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7396 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7397 and using the MCR instruction.
7398 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7399 an ARM register.)
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7403 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7404 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7405 and the MRC instruction.
7406 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7407 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7408 an ARM register.)
7409 @end deffn
7410
7411 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7412 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7413 core mode if necessary.
7414 @end deffn
7415
7416 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7417 @cindex ARM semihosting
7418 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7419
7420 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7421 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7422 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7423 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7424 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7425 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7426 @end deffn
7427
7428 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7429 @cindex ARM semihosting
7430 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
7431 status.
7432
7433 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
7434 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
7435 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
7436 debugger.
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7440 @cindex ARMv4
7441 @cindex ARMv5
7442
7443 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7444 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7445 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7446 variant.
7447
7448 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7449 @cindex ARM7
7450 @cindex ARM9
7451
7452 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7453 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7454 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7455 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7456
7457 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7458 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7459 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7460 instead of breakpoints.
7461 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7462
7463 This should be
7464 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7465 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7466 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7467 @end deffn
7468
7469 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7470 @cindex DCC
7471 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7472 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7473 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7474
7475 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7476 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7477 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7478 @end deffn
7479
7480 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7481 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7482 that don't check completion of the operation.
7483 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7484
7485 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7486 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7487 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7488 @end deffn
7489
7490 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7491 @cindex ARM720T
7492
7493 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7494 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7495 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7496 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7497
7498 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7499 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7500 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7501
7502 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7503 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7504 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7505 @end deffn
7506
7507 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7508 @cindex ARM9
7509
7510 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7511 integer processors.
7512 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7513
7514 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7515 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7516 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7517 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7518
7519 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7520 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7521 @cindex vector_catch
7522 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7523 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7524 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7525 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7526 to those hardware vectors.
7527
7528 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7529 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7530 vector catch hardware to intercept
7531 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7532 @option{none} of them,
7533 or a list with one or more of the following:
7534 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7535 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7536 @end deffn
7537
7538 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7539 @cindex ARM920T
7540
7541 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7542 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7543 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7544 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7545 and ARM9 commands.
7546
7547 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7548 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7549 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7553 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7554 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7555 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7556 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7557 (Not all registers can be written.)
7558 @end deffn
7559
7560 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7561 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7562 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7563
7564 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7565 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7566 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7567 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7568 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7569 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7570 @end deffn
7571
7572 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7573 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7577 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7581 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7582
7583 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7584 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7585 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7586 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7587 and ARM9 commands.
7588
7589 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7590 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7591
7592 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7593 Print information about the caches found.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7597 @cindex ARM966E
7598
7599 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7600 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7601 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7602 and ARM9 commands.
7603
7604 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7605 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7606 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7607 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7608 ARM966E-S TRM.
7609 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7610 as required for BIST support.
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 @subsection XScale specific commands
7614 @cindex XScale
7615
7616 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7617
7618 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7619 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7620 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7621 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7622 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7623 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7624 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7625
7626 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7627 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7628 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7629 the mini-IC.
7630
7631 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7632 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7633 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7634 code layout in memory:
7635 @example
7636 _vectors:
7637 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7638 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7639 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7640 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7641 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7642 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7643 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7644 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7645 .org 0x100
7646 .long real_reset_vector
7647 .long real_ui_handler
7648 .long real_swi_handler
7649 .long real_pf_abort
7650 .long real_data_abort
7651 .long 0 /* unused */
7652 .long real_irq_handler
7653 .long real_fiq_handler
7654 @end example
7655
7656 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7657 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7658 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7659 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7660 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7661 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7662 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7663 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7664 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7665 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7666 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7667 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7668 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7669 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7670 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7671 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7672 software.
7673
7674 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7675 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7676 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7677 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7678
7679 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7680 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7681 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7682 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7683 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7684 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7685 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7686 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7687 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7688
7689 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7690 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7691
7692 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7693 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7694 @end deffn
7695
7696 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7697 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7698 @end deffn
7699
7700 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7701 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7702 @end deffn
7703
7704 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7705 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7706 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7707 @end deffn
7708
7709 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7710 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7714 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7715 @end deffn
7716
7717 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7718 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7719 @end deffn
7720
7721 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7722 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7726 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7727 @end deffn
7728
7729 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7730 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7731 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7732 and modifying how it is emptied.
7733 @end deffn
7734
7735 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7736 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7737 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7738 The image @var{type} may be one of
7739 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7740 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7741 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7742 @end deffn
7743
7744 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7745 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7746 @cindex vector_catch
7747 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7748 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7749
7750 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7751 @example
7752 0x01 Trap Reset
7753 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7754 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7755 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7756 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7757 0x20 reserved
7758 0x40 Trap IRQ
7759 0x80 Trap FIQ
7760 @end example
7761 @end deffn
7762
7763 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7764 @cindex vector_table
7765
7766 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7767 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7768 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7769 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7770 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7771
7772 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7773
7774 @end deffn
7775
7776 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7777 @cindex ARMv6
7778
7779 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7780 @cindex ARM11
7781
7782 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7783 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7784 which is enabled by default.
7785 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7786 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7787 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7788 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7789 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7790 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7791 @end deffn
7792
7793 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7794 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7795 which is enabled by default.
7796 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7797 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7798 @end deffn
7799
7800 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7801 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7802 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7803 they are disabled by default.
7804 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7805 @end deffn
7806
7807 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7808 @cindex vector_catch
7809 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7810 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7811 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7812
7813 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7814 for certain hardware events.
7815 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7816 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7817 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7818 @end deffn
7819
7820 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7821 @cindex ARMv7
7822
7823 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7824 @cindex Debug Access Port
7825 @cindex DAP
7826 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7827 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7828 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7829
7830 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7831 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7832 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7833 @end deffn
7834
7835 @deffn Command {dap apreg} ap_num reg [value]
7836 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
7837 or set a new value @var{value}.
7838 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
7839 @end deffn
7840
7841 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7842 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7843 @end deffn
7844
7845 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7846 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7847 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7851 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7852 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7853 @end deffn
7854
7855 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7856 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7857 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7858 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7859 @end deffn
7860
7861 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7862 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7863 Defaulting to 0.
7864 @end deffn
7865
7866 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7867 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7868 Disabled by default
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871
7872 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7873 @cindex Cortex-A
7874
7875 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7876 display information about target caches
7877 @end deffn
7878
7879 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
7880 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
7881 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
7882 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
7883 Defaults to 'off'.
7884 @end deffn
7885
7886 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7887 Initialize core debug
7888 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7889 @end deffn
7890
7891 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7892 Disable SMP mode
7893 @end deffn
7894
7895 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7896 Enable SMP mode
7897 @end deffn
7898
7899 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7900 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7904 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7908 configure l2x cache
7909 @end deffn
7910
7911
7912 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7913 @cindex Cortex-R
7914
7915 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7916 Initialize core debug
7917 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7918 @end deffn
7919
7920 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7921 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7922 @end deffn
7923
7924
7925 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7926 @cindex tracing
7927 @cindex SWO
7928 @cindex SWV
7929 @cindex TPIU
7930 @cindex ITM
7931 @cindex ETM
7932
7933 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7934 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7935 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7936
7937 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7938 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7939 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7940 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7941
7942 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7943 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7944 debugger adapter features.
7945
7946 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7947 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7948
7949 Command options:
7950 @itemize @minus
7951 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7952 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7953 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7954 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7955 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7956 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7957 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7958 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7959 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7960 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7961 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7962 coding;
7963 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7964 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7965 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7966 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7967 data is to be output via SWO;
7968 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7969 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7970 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7971 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7972 rate automatically.
7973 @end itemize
7974
7975 Example usage:
7976 @enumerate
7977 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7978 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7979 enough to:
7980 @example
7981 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7982 ...
7983 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7984 ...
7985 @end example
7986 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7987 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7988 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7989 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7990 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7991 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7992 @example
7993 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7994 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7995 @end example
7996 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7997 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7998 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7999 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8000 @example
8001 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
8002 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8003 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8004 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8005 @end example
8006 @end enumerate
8007 @end deffn
8008
8009 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8010 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8011 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8012 @end deffn
8013
8014 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8015 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8016 @end deffn
8017
8018 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8019 @cindex Cortex-M
8020
8021 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8022 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8023
8024 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
8025 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8026 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8027 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8028 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8029 the step command leaves with the core running.
8030
8031 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
8032 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
8033 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
8034
8035 Default is @option{auto}.
8036 @end deffn
8037
8038 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8039 @cindex vector_catch
8040 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8041 for certain hardware events.
8042
8043 Parameters request interception of
8044 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8045 @option{none} of them,
8046 or one or more of the following:
8047 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8048 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8049 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8050 @option{irq_err},
8051 @option{state_err},
8052 @option{chk_err}, or
8053 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8054 @option{reset}.
8055 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8056 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8057 are mapped to HardFault.
8058 UsageFault checks for
8059 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8060 must also be explicitly enabled.
8061
8062 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8063 @end deffn
8064
8065 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8066 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8067 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8068 @itemize @minus
8069 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8070 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8071 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8072 @end itemize
8073 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8074 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8075 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8076 the peripherals.
8077 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8078 @end deffn
8079
8080 @section Intel Architecture
8081
8082 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8083 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8084 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8085 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8086 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8087 @itemize
8088 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8089 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8090 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8091 @end itemize
8092
8093 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8094 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8095 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8096
8097 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8098 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8099 @end deffn
8100
8101 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8102 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8106 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8107 @end deffn
8108
8109 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8110 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8111 @end deffn
8112
8113 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8114 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8115 @end deffn
8116
8117 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8118 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8119 @end deffn
8120
8121 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8122
8123 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8124 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8125
8126 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8127 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8128 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8129 @end deffn
8130 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8131 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8132
8133 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8134
8135 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8136 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8137 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8138 @end deffn
8139
8140 @subsection Registers commands
8141 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8142 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8143 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8144
8145 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8146
8147 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8148 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8149 and "timer" groups.
8150
8151 @emph{example:}
8152 @example
8153 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8154 @end example
8155
8156
8157 @end deffn
8158 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8159 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8160
8161 @emph{group} can be "system",
8162 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8163 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8167 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8168 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8169 @cindex tracing
8170 @cindex libdcc
8171 @cindex DCC
8172 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8173 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8174 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8175 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8176
8177 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8178 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8179 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8180 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8181 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8182 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8183
8184 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8185 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8186 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8187 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8188 The target being debugged may
8189 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8190 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8191 each supported by a command:
8192
8193 @itemize
8194 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8195 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8196 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8197 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8198
8199 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8200 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8201 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8202
8203 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8204 and then displayed at any time.
8205 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8206
8207 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8208 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8209 @end itemize
8210
8211 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8212 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8213 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8214 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8215 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8216 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8217 does the same thing.
8218
8219 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8220 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8221 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8222 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8223 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8224
8225 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8226 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8227 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8228 @end deffn
8229
8230 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8231 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8232 in the order they triggered.
8233 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8234 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8235 history records.
8236 @end deffn
8237
8238 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8239 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8240 they have been triggered.
8241 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8242 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8243 and associates it with that identifier.
8244
8245 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8246 are not related except by this command.
8247 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8248 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8249 @end deffn
8250
8251
8252 @node JTAG Commands
8253 @chapter JTAG Commands
8254 @cindex JTAG Commands
8255 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8256 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8257 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8258 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8259 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8260
8261 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8262 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8263
8264 @itemize @bullet
8265 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8266 devices such as a CPUs.
8267 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8268 standard state machine (in parallel)
8269 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8270 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8271 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8272 while the reading previous ones.
8273 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8274 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8275 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8276 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8277 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8278 registers.
8279 @end itemize
8280
8281 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8282
8283 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8284 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8285 the order of TAP state transitions.
8286 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8287 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8288 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8289 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8290 these commands are not available.
8291
8292 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8293 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8294 that specify the entire register.
8295 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8296 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8297 The return value holds the original value of each
8298 of those fields.
8299
8300 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8301 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8302 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8303 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8304 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8305
8306 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8307 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8308
8309 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8310 in that state.
8311 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8312 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8313 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8314
8315 @quotation Warning
8316 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8317 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8318 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8319 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8320 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8321 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8322 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8323 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8324 @end quotation
8325 @end deffn
8326
8327 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8328 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8329 This may be used for performance tuning.
8330
8331 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8332 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8333 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8334 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8335 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8336 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8337 @end deffn
8338
8339 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8340 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8341 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8342 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8343 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8344 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8345
8346 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8347 in that state.
8348 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8349 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8350 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8351
8352 @quotation Note
8353 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8354 register values, unlike data register values.
8355 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8356 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8357 @end quotation
8358 @end deffn
8359
8360 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8361 Set values of reset signals.
8362 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8363 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8364 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8365 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8366 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8367 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8368 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8369
8370 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8371 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8372 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8373 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8374 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8375 instead of the TRST signal.
8376 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8377 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8378 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8379 with handlers for that event.
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8383 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8384 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8385 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8386 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8387 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8388 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8389 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8390 The final state must also be stable.
8391 @end deffn
8392
8393 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8394 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8395 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8396 Instructions often need some time
8397 to execute before they take effect.
8398 @end deffn
8399
8400 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8401 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8402
8403 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8404 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8405 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8406 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8407 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8408 @end deffn
8409
8410 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8411 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8412 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8413 must also be enabled.
8414 Default is enabled.
8415 @end deffn
8416
8417 @section TAP state names
8418 @cindex TAP state names
8419
8420 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8421 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8422 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8423 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8424
8425 @itemize @bullet
8426 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8427 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8428 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8429 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8430 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8431 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8432 through the data register
8433 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8434 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8435 for update or more shifting
8436 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8437 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8438 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8439 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8440 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8441 through the instruction register
8442 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8443 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8444 for update or more shifting
8445 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8446 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8447 @end itemize
8448
8449 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8450 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8451 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8452 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8453
8454 @itemize @bullet
8455 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8456 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8457 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8458 may not be as expected.
8459 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8460 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8461 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8462 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8463 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8464 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8465 @end itemize
8466
8467 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8468 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8469
8470 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8471 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8472 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8473 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8474
8475 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8476 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8477 @cindex SVF
8478
8479 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8480 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8481 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8482 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8483
8484 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8485 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8486 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8487 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8488 each command is logged before it is executed.
8489 @end deffn
8490
8491 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8492 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8493 @cindex XSVF
8494
8495 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8496 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8497 Xilinx devices.
8498 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8499 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8500
8501 @quotation Important
8502 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8503 @end quotation
8504
8505 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8506 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8507 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8508 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8509 that TAP.
8510 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8511 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8512 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8513 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8514 @end deffn
8515
8516 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8517 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8518 after building the software.
8519 You may find them useful:
8520
8521 @itemize
8522 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8523 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8524 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8525 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8526 @end itemize
8527
8528 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8529 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8530 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8531 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8532 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8533 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8534 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8535
8536
8537 @node Utility Commands
8538 @chapter Utility Commands
8539 @cindex Utility Commands
8540
8541 @section RAM testing
8542 @cindex RAM testing
8543
8544 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8545 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8546 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8547 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8548 hardware problems.
8549
8550 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8551 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8552 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8553 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8554
8555 Load the memory testing functions with
8556
8557 @example
8558 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8559 @end example
8560
8561 to get access to the following facilities:
8562
8563 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8564 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8565 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8566 @end deffn
8567
8568 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8569 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8570 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8571 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8572 @end deffn
8573
8574 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8575 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8576 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8577 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8581 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8582 @end deffn
8583
8584 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8585 @cindex Firmware recovery
8586
8587 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8588 devices recovery with JTAG.
8589
8590 For quickstart instructions run:
8591 @example
8592 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8593 @end example
8594
8595 @node TFTP
8596 @chapter TFTP
8597 @cindex TFTP
8598 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8599 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8600
8601 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8602 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8603 server (tftpd). For example,
8604
8605 @example
8606 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8607 @end example
8608
8609 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8610 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8611
8612 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8613 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8614 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8615 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8616
8617 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8618 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8619 @cindex GDB
8620 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8621 to debug remote targets.
8622 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8623
8624 @itemize
8625 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8626 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8627 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8628 as shown in this chapter.
8629 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8630 that also will probably need to be configured.
8631 @end itemize
8632
8633 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8634 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8635 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8636 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8637 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8638 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8639
8640 @section Connecting to GDB
8641 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8642 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8643 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8644 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8645 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8646
8647 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8648
8649 @enumerate
8650 @item
8651 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8652 @example
8653 target remote localhost:3333
8654 @end example
8655 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8656
8657 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8658 @example
8659 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8660 @end example
8661 @item
8662 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8663 @example
8664 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8665 @end example
8666 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8667 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8668 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8669 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8670 @end enumerate
8671
8672 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8673 GDB command line.
8674
8675 @section Sample GDB session startup
8676
8677 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8678 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8679 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8680 small ARM program.
8681 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8682 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8683
8684 @example
8685 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8686 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8687 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8688 ...
8689 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8690 ...
8691 (gdb) load
8692 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8693 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8694 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8695 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8696 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8697 (gdb) continue
8698 Continuing.
8699 ...
8700 @end example
8701
8702 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8703 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8704 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8705 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8706
8707 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8708
8709 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8710 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8711 packet size and the device's memory map.
8712 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8713 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8714 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8715
8716 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8717 You may need to set those up by hand.
8718 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8719 something like:
8720
8721 @example
8722 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8723 @end example
8724
8725 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8726
8727 @example
8728 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8729 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8730 @end example
8731
8732 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8733 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8734 do not have such restrictions.
8735
8736 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8737 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8738 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8739
8740 @example
8741 define hook-step
8742 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8743 end
8744 define hookpost-step
8745 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8746 end
8747 @end example
8748
8749 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8750 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8751 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8752 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8753
8754 @section Programming using GDB
8755 @cindex Programming using GDB
8756 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8757
8758 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8759 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8760 @example
8761 gdb_memory_map disable
8762 @end example
8763 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8764 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8765 working area.
8766
8767 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8768 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8769 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8770 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8771
8772 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8773 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8774
8775 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8776 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8777 @example
8778 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8779 @end example
8780
8781 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8782 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8783
8784 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8785 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8786 will be used.
8787
8788 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8789 script can be executed:
8790 @example
8791 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8792 @end example
8793
8794 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8795 can be used.
8796 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8797 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8798 @cindex SMP
8799 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8800 @itemize @bullet
8801 @item j - smp status request
8802 @item J - smp set request
8803 @end itemize
8804
8805 OpenOCD implements :
8806 @itemize @bullet
8807 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8808 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8809 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8810 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8811 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8812 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8813 @end itemize
8814
8815 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8816 @itemize @bullet
8817 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8818 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8819 @example
8820 set $_core 1
8821 #Jc01 packet is sent
8822 print $_core
8823 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8824 @end example
8825
8826 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8827 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8828
8829 @example
8830 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8831 define toggle0
8832 maint packet Jc0
8833 continue
8834 main packet Jc-1
8835 end
8836 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8837 define toggle1
8838 maint packet Jc1
8839 continue
8840 main packet Jc-1
8841 end
8842 @end example
8843 @end itemize
8844
8845 @section RTOS Support
8846 @cindex RTOS Support
8847 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8848
8849 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8850 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8851
8852 @* An example setup is below:
8853
8854 @example
8855 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8856 @end example
8857
8858 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8859
8860 Currently supported rtos's include:
8861 @itemize @bullet
8862 @item @option{eCos}
8863 @item @option{ThreadX}
8864 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8865 @item @option{linux}
8866 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8867 @item @option{embKernel}
8868 @item @option{mqx}
8869 @item @option{uCOS-III}
8870 @end itemize
8871
8872 @quotation Note
8873 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8874 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8875 @end quotation
8876
8877 @table @code
8878 @item eCos symbols
8879 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8880 @item ThreadX symbols
8881 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8882 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8883 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8884 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8885 @tex
8886 \begingroup
8887 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8888 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8889 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8890 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8891 \par
8892 \endgroup
8893 @end tex
8894 @item linux symbols
8895 init_task.
8896 @item ChibiOS symbols
8897 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8898 @item embKernel symbols
8899 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8900 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8901 @item mqx symbols
8902 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8903 @item uC/OS-III symbols
8904 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
8905 @end table
8906
8907 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8908 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
8909
8910 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8911 along with the project:
8912
8913 @table @code
8914 @item FreeRTOS
8915 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8916 @item uC/OS-III
8917 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
8918 @end table
8919
8920 @node Tcl Scripting API
8921 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8922 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8923 @cindex Tcl scripts
8924 @section API rules
8925
8926 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8927 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8928 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8929
8930 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8931 pair list and lists.
8932
8933 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8934 list.
8935
8936 @example
8937 > set foo(me) Duane
8938 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8939 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8940 > set foo(duck) Donald
8941 @end example
8942
8943 If one does this:
8944
8945 @example
8946 > set foo
8947 @end example
8948
8949 The result is:
8950
8951 @example
8952 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8953 @end example
8954
8955 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8956
8957 @verbatim
8958 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8959 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8960 }
8961 @end verbatim
8962
8963 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8964 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8965
8966 @section Internal low-level Commands
8967
8968 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8969 invoke directly.
8970
8971 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8972 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8973 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8974
8975 @itemize @bullet
8976 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8977
8978 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8979 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8980
8981 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8982 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8983
8984 Return information about the flash banks
8985
8986 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8987
8988 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8989 its execution. Example:
8990
8991 @example
8992 > capture "reset init"
8993 @end example
8994
8995 @end itemize
8996
8997 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8998 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8999 called "flash_banks".
9000
9001 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
9002
9003 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
9004 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
9005 holds one of the following values:
9006
9007 @itemize @bullet
9008 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
9009 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
9010 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
9011 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
9012 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
9013 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
9014 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
9015 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
9016 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
9017 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
9018 @end itemize
9019
9020 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
9021
9022 @quotation Note
9023 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
9024 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
9025 @code{jim_platform} (because it
9026 is jim, not real tcl).
9027 @end quotation
9028
9029 @section Tcl RPC server
9030 @cindex RPC
9031
9032 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
9033 commands and receive the results.
9034
9035 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
9036 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
9037 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
9038 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
9039 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
9040
9041 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
9042 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
9043 @command{capture} command.
9044
9045 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9046
9047 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9048 @cindex RPC Notifications
9049
9050 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9051 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9052
9053 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9054 in the following format.
9055
9056 @verbatim
9057 type target_event event [event-name]
9058 type target_state state [state-name]
9059 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9060 @end verbatim
9061
9062 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9063 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9064 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9065 Defaults to off.
9066
9067 @end deffn
9068
9069 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9070 @cindex RPC trace output
9071
9072 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9073 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9074
9075 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9076
9077 @verbatim
9078 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9079 @end verbatim
9080
9081 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9082 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9083 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9084 Defaults to off.
9085
9086 See an example application here:
9087 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9088
9089 @end deffn
9090
9091 @node FAQ
9092 @chapter FAQ
9093 @cindex faq
9094 @enumerate
9095 @anchor{faqrtck}
9096 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9097 @cindex RTCK
9098 @cindex adaptive clocking
9099 @*
9100
9101 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9102 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9103 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9104 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9105
9106 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9107 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9108 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9109 @enumerate
9110 @item
9111 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9112 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9113 @item
9114 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9115 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9116 @end enumerate
9117
9118 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9119 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9120 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9121 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9122 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9123 power).
9124
9125 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9126 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9127 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9128 ARM926 scenario).
9129 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9130 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9131 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9132
9133 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9134 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9135 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9136 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9137
9138 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9139
9140 In order to make use of this,
9141 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9142 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9143
9144 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9145 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9146 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9147 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9148 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9149
9150 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9151 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9152 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9153 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9154
9155 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9156 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9157 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9158 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9159 with a CPLD.
9160 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9161 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9162 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9163 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9164 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9165 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9166
9167 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9168
9169 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9170
9171 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9172 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9173 depending on the chips on your board.
9174 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9175 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9176 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9177
9178 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9179 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9180 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9181
9182 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9183 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9184 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9185 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9186
9187 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9188 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9189 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9190 this way.
9191
9192 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9193 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9194 clock rate.
9195 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9196 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9197 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9198
9199 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9200
9201 @example
9202 # Example: 1.234MHz
9203 adapter_khz 1234
9204 @end example
9205
9206
9207 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9208
9209 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9210 around Windows filenames.
9211
9212 @example
9213 > echo \a
9214
9215 > echo @{\a@}
9216 \a
9217 > echo "\a"
9218
9219 >
9220 @end example
9221
9222
9223 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9224
9225 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9226 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9227 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9228
9229 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9230 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9231 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9232
9233 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9234 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9235 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9236
9237 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9238
9239 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9240 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9241 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9242 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9243
9244 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9245 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9246 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9247
9248 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9249 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9250
9251 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9252 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9253 memory read caused data abort".
9254
9255 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9256 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9257 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9258 be done, feel free to add this here.
9259
9260 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9261 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9262 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9263 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9264 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9265 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9266 gracefully stops.
9267
9268 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9269 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9270 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9271
9272 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9273 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9274 bytes. Painful...
9275
9276
9277 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9278 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9279
9280 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9281 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9282 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9283 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9284 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9285 reset, everything else should work fine.
9286
9287 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9288 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9289 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9290 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9291
9292 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9293 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9294 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9295 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9296
9297 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9298
9299 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9300 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9301 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9302
9303 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9304 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9305
9306 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9307 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9308 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9309 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9310 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9311 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9312 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9313 clock frequency?
9314
9315 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9316 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9317 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9318 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9319 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9320
9321 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9322
9323 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9324 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9325 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9326 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9327 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9328 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9329 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9330
9331 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9332
9333 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9334 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9335 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9336 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9337
9338 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9339 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9340 particular order?
9341
9342 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9343 the same order used by the hardware.
9344
9345 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9346 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9347 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9348 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9349 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9350 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9351
9352 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9353 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9354 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9355 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9356
9357 @itemize @bullet
9358 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9359 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9360 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9361 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9362 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9363 @end itemize
9364
9365 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9366
9367 @itemize @bullet
9368 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9369 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9370 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9371 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9372 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9373 @end itemize
9374
9375
9376 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9377 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9378 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9379
9380 TODO.
9381
9382 @end enumerate
9383
9384 @node Tcl Crash Course
9385 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9386 @cindex Tcl
9387
9388 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9389 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9390 how the Tcl scripts work.
9391
9392 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9393 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9394 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9395 OpenOCD.
9396
9397 @section Tcl Rule #1
9398 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9399 @enumerate
9400 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9401 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9402 @end enumerate
9403
9404 The Tcl equal is this:
9405
9406 @enumerate
9407 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9408 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9409 @end enumerate
9410
9411 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9412 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9413
9414 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9415 There is a second pair of rules.
9416 @enumerate
9417 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9418 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9419 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9420 in Tcl.
9421 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9422 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9423 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9424 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9425 @end enumerate
9426
9427 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9428 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9429 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9430 Everything is a string}
9431
9432 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9433 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9434 difference is subtle.
9435 @enumerate
9436 @item Parse Time
9437 @item Evaluation Time
9438 @end enumerate
9439
9440 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9441 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9442 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9443
9444 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9445 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9446 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9447 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9448
9449 @itemize @bullet
9450 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9451 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9452 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9453 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9454 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9455 @example
9456 # bash example
9457 X=`date`
9458 echo "The Date is: $X"
9459 # Tcl example
9460 set X [date]
9461 puts "The Date is: $X"
9462 @end example
9463 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9464 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9465 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9466 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9467 is a string}
9468 @example
9469 set x "Dinner"
9470 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9471 @end example
9472 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9473 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9474 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9475 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9476 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9477 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9478 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9479 @end itemize
9480
9481 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9482
9483 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9484
9485 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9486
9487 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9488 the normal way.
9489
9490 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9491 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9492 line is immedatly executed.
9493
9494 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9495 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9496
9497 @subsection Command Execution
9498
9499 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9500 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9501 control flow operators.
9502
9503 Commands are executed like this:
9504
9505 @enumerate
9506 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9507 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9508 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9509 @end enumerate
9510
9511 It sort of works like this:
9512 @example
9513 for(;;)@{
9514 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9515
9516 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9517
9518 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9519 @}
9520 @end example
9521
9522 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9523 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9524 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9525 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9526 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9527 ``LookupCommand()''
9528
9529 @subsection The FOR command
9530
9531 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9532 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9533 command just like any other command.
9534
9535 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9536 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9537 are:
9538
9539 @enumerate 0
9540 @item The ascii text 'for'
9541 @item The start text
9542 @item The test expression
9543 @item The next text
9544 @item The body text
9545 @end enumerate
9546
9547 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9548 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9549 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9550 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9551
9552 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9553 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9554
9555 @example
9556 int
9557 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9558 int *argc,
9559 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9560 @end example
9561
9562 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9563 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9564 still operates in the same basic way.
9565
9566 @subsection FOR command implementation
9567
9568 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9569 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9570
9571 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9572
9573 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9574
9575 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9576 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9577 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9578
9579 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9580 expression and returns a value.
9581
9582 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9583 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9584 @example
9585 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9586
9587 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9588
9589 int
9590 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9591 int argc,
9592 char **argv )
9593 @{
9594 if( argc != 5 )@{
9595 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9596 return ERROR;
9597 @}
9598
9599 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9600
9601 // Execute the start statement.
9602 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9603
9604 // Top of loop test
9605 for(;;)@{
9606 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9607 if( i == 0 )
9608 break;
9609
9610 // Execute the body
9611 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9612
9613 // Execute the LOOP part
9614 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9615 @}
9616
9617 // Return no error
9618 SetResult( interp, "" );
9619 return SUCCESS;
9620 @}
9621 @end example
9622
9623 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9624 in the same basic way.
9625
9626 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9627
9628 @subsection source and find commands
9629 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9630 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9631 @*Remember the parsing rules
9632 @enumerate
9633 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9634 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9635 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9636 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9637 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9638 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9639 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9640 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9641 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9642 @end enumerate
9643 @subsection format command
9644 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9645 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9646 @b{sprintf()}.
9647 @b{Example}
9648 @example
9649 set x 6
9650 set y 7
9651 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9652 @end example
9653 @enumerate
9654 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9655 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9656 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9657 @* Refer to Rule #1
9658 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9659 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9660 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9661 @end enumerate
9662 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9663 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9664 @example
9665 #1 Good
9666 proc someproc @{@} @{
9667 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9668 @}
9669 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9670 #2 Good - no variables
9671 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9672 #3 Good Curly Braces
9673 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9674 puts "Time: [date]"
9675 @}
9676 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9677 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9678 @end example
9679 @enumerate
9680 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9681 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9682 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9683 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9684 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9685 command.
9686 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9687 @*There are 4 examples:
9688 @enumerate
9689 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9690 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9691 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9692 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9693 @end enumerate
9694
9695 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9696 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9697 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9698
9699 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9700 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9701 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9702 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9703 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9704 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9705 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9706 @end enumerate
9707 @subsection Global Variables
9708 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9709 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9710 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9711 @example
9712 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9713 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9714 global x #Global variable X
9715 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9716 @}
9717 @end example
9718 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9719 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9720 @example
9721 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9722 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9723 # Create var name
9724 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9725 # Make it a global
9726 global $vn
9727 # Set it.
9728 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9729 @}
9730 @end example
9731 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9732 @example
9733 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9734 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9735 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9736 @}
9737 @end example
9738
9739 @include fdl.texi
9740
9741 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9742 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9743 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9744 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9745 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9746 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9747
9748 @printindex cp
9749
9750 @node Command and Driver Index
9751 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9752 @printindex fn
9753
9754 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)